manual: fix usb_blaster_pin command syntax and description
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB JLINK based
453 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
454 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
460 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
464 @end itemize
465
466 @section USB RLINK based
467 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
468 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
469 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
470
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
478 @end itemize
479
480 @section USB ST-LINK based
481 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
482 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
483
484 @itemize @bullet
485 @item @b{ST-LINK}
486 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
487 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
488 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
489 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
490 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
491 @end itemize
492
493 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
494 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
495 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
496 @itemize @bullet
497 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
498 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
499 @end itemize
500
501 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
502 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
503 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
504 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
505
506 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
507 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
508 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
509
510 @section USB Other
511 @itemize @bullet
512 @item @b{USBprog}
513 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
514
515 @item @b{USB - Presto}
516 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
517
518 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
519 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
520
521 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
522 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
523
524 @item @b{Buspirate}
525 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
526
527 @item @b{opendous}
528 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
529
530 @item @b{estick}
531 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
532
533 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
534 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
535 @end itemize
536
537 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
538
539 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
540 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
541 these on the market.
542
543 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
544 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
545 of USB-based ones.
546
547 @itemize @bullet
548
549 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
550 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
551
552 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
553 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
554 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
555
556 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Wiggler2}
560 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
561
562 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
563 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
564
565 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
566 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
567
568 @item @b{arm-jtag}
569 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
570
571 @item @b{chameleon}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
573
574 @item @b{Triton}
575 @* Unknown.
576
577 @item @b{Lattice}
578 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
579 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
580
581 @item @b{flashlink}
582 @* From ST Microsystems;
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
584
585 @end itemize
586
587 @section Other...
588 @itemize @bullet
589
590 @item @b{ep93xx}
591 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
592
593 @item @b{at91rm9200}
594 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
595
596 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
597 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @end itemize
604
605 @node About Jim-Tcl
606 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex tcl
609
610 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
611 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
612 command interpreter.
613
614 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
615 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
616 much of anything about Tcl.
617 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
618
619 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
620 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
621 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
622 OpenOCD mailing list.
623
624 @itemize @bullet
625 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
626 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
627 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
628 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
629 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
630 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
631
632 @item @b{Missing Features}
633 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
634 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
635 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
636 enabled in OpenOCD.
637
638 @item @b{Scripts}
639 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
640 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
641 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
642
643 @item @b{Commands}
644 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
645 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
646 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
647 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
648
649 @item @b{Historical Note}
650 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
651 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
652 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
653 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
654
655 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
656 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
657 @end itemize
658
659 @node Running
660 @chapter Running
661 @cindex command line options
662 @cindex logfile
663 @cindex directory search
664
665 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
666 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
667 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
668 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
669 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
670 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
671 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
672
673 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
674 tell it how each debug session should work.
675 The @option{--help} option shows:
676 @verbatim
677 bash$ openocd --help
678
679 --help | -h display this help
680 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
681 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
682 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
683 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
684 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
685 --command | -c run <command>
686 @end verbatim
687
688 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
689 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
690 To specify one or more different
691 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
692
693 @example
694 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
695 @end example
696
697 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
698 @enumerate
699 @item the current directory,
700 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
701 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
702 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129 @end deffn
2130
2131 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2132 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2133 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2134 output from the Tcl engine.
2135 Intended as a machine interface.
2136 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2137 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2138
2139 @end deffn
2140
2141 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2142 Specify or query the
2143 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2144 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2145 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2146 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2147 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2148 @end deffn
2149
2150 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2151 @section GDB Configuration
2152 @cindex GDB
2153 @cindex GDB configuration
2154 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2155 The ones listed here are static and global.
2156 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2157 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2158
2159 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2160 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2161 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2162 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2163 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2164 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2165 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2166 @end deffn
2167
2168 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2169 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2170 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2171 vFlash packet is received.
2172 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2173 @end deffn
2174
2175 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2176 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2177 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2178 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2179 for flash programming to work.
2180 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2181 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2185 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2186 by GDB memory read packets.
2187 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2188 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2189 @end deffn
2190
2191 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2192 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2193 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2197 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2198
2199 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @anchor{eventpolling}
2203 @section Event Polling
2204
2205 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2206 where significant events can happen at any time.
2207 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2208 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2209 or to GDB.
2210
2211 Examples of such events include:
2212
2213 @itemize
2214 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2215 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2216 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2217 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2218 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2219 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2220 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2221 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2222 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2223 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2224 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2225 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2226 @end itemize
2227
2228 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2229 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2230 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2231 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2232 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2233
2234 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2235 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2236 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2237 to the various active targets.
2238 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2239 which is normally done in the background.
2240
2241 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2242 Poll the current target for its current state.
2243 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2244 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2245 specific information about the current state is printed.
2246 An optional parameter
2247 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2248
2249 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2250 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2251 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2252 @example
2253 > poll
2254 background polling: on
2255 target state: halted
2256 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2257 current mode: Supervisor
2258 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2259 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2260 >
2261 @end example
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2265 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2266 @cindex config file, interface
2267 @cindex interface config file
2268
2269 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2270 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2271 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2272
2273 @quotation Note
2274 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2275 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2276 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2277 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2278 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2279 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2280 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2281 @end quotation
2282
2283 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2284 through commands in an interface configuration
2285 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2286 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2287
2288 @example
2289 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2290 @end example
2291
2292 These commands tell
2293 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2294 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2295
2296 @example
2297 # jlink interface
2298 interface jlink
2299 @end example
2300
2301 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2302
2303
2304 @section Interface Configuration
2305
2306 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2307 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2308 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2309
2310 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2311 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2312 target.
2313 @end deffn
2314
2315 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2316 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2317 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2318 @end deffn
2319 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2320 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2321 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2322 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2323 the hardware can support.
2324 @end deffn
2325
2326
2327
2328 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2329 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332 @section Interface Drivers
2333
2334 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2335 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2336 available at run time.
2337
2338 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2339 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2340 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2341 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2342
2343 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2344 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2345 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2346 @end deffn
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2349 Displays status of RTCK option.
2350 Optionally sets that option first.
2351 @end deffn
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2355 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2356 This has one driver-specific command:
2357
2358 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2359 Logs some status
2360 @end deffn
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2364 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2365 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2366 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2367 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2368 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2372 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2373
2374 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2375 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2376 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2377 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2378 @example
2379 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2380 @end example
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2384 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2385 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2389 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2394 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2395 @end deffn
2396
2397 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2398 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2402 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2403
2404 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2405 recommended as its replacement.
2406
2407 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2408 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2411 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2412 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2413 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2414 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2418 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2419 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2420 is connected to the host.
2421 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2422 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2423 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2424 @end deffn
2425
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2427 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2428 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2429 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2432 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2433 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2434 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2435 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2436 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2437 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2438 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2439 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2440 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2441 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2442 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2443 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2444 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2445 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2446 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2447 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2448 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2449 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2450 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2451 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2452 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2453 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2454 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2455 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2456 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2457 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2458 @end itemize
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2462 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2463 default values are used.
2464 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2465 @example
2466 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2467 @end example
2468 @end deffn
2469
2470 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2471 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2472 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2473 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2474 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2475 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2476 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2480 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2481 The default value is 1.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 For example, the interface config file for a
2485 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2486
2487 @example
2488 interface ft2232
2489 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2490 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2491 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2492 @end example
2493 @end deffn
2494
2495 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2496 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2497 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2498 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2499 interface driver.
2500
2501 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2502 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2503 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2504
2505 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2506 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2507 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2508
2509 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2510 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2511 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2512 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2513 will be used for their customary purpose.
2514
2515 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2516 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2517 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2518 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2519
2520 @itemize @minus
2521 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2522 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2523 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2524 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2525 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2526 switching data and direction as necessary
2527 @end itemize
2528
2529 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2530 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2531
2532 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2533 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2534 default values are used.
2535 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2536 @example
2537 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2538 @end example
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2542 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2543 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2544 during device selection.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2548 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2549 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2550 is connected to the host.
2551 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2552 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2553 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2554 @end deffn
2555
2556 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2557 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2558 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2562 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2563 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2564 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2565 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2566 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2567 and initially asserted reset signals.
2568 @end deffn
2569
2570 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2571 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2572 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2573 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2574 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2575 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2576 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2577 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2578 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2579
2580 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2581 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2582 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2583 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2584 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2585 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2586
2587 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2588 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2589 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2590 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2591 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2592 are always driven by the FTDI.
2593
2594 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2595 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2596 @var{name}.
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2600 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2601 @itemize @minus
2602 @item @option{0}, drive low
2603 @item @option{1}, drive high
2604 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2605 @end itemize
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2609 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2613 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2614 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2615 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2616
2617 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2618 processors which are being simulated.
2619
2620 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2621 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2622 sockets instead of TCP.
2623 @end deffn
2624
2625 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2626 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2627 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2631 something like:
2632
2633 @example
2634 interface remote_bitbang
2635 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2636 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2637 @end example
2638
2639 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2640 named mysocket:
2641
2642 @example
2643 interface remote_bitbang
2644 remote_bitbang_port 0
2645 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2646 @end example
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2650 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2651 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2652 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2655 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2656 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2657 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2658 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2662 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2663 default values are used.
2664 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2665 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2666 @example
2667 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2668 @end example
2669 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2670 @example
2671 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2672 @end example
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2676 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2677 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2678 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2679 target board.
2680
2681 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2682 @example
2683 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2684 reset_config srst_only
2685 @end example
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2691 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2692 This has one driver-specific command:
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2695 Display either the address of the I/O port
2696 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2697 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2698 This is a write-once setting.
2699 @end deffn
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2703 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2704
2705 @quotation Compatibility Note
2706 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2707 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2708 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2709 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2710 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2711 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2712 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2713 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2714 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2715 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2716 @end quotation
2717
2718 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2719 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2722 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2725 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2726 @end deffn
2727 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2728 Display the J-Link configuration.
2729 @end deffn
2730 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2731 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2732 @end deffn
2733 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2734 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2735 @end deffn
2736 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2737 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2738 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2739 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2742 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2743 @end deffn
2744 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2745 Reset the current configuration.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2748 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2749 @end deffn
2750 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2751 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2754 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2755 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2756
2757 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2758 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2759 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2760
2761 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2766 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2767 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2768 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2769 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2772 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2773 This is a write-once setting.
2774 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2775
2776 @itemize @minus
2777 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2778 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2779 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2780 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2781 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2782 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2783 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2784 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2785 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2786 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2787 some versions of
2788 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2789 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2790 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2791 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2792 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2793 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2794 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2795 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2796 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2797 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2798 @end itemize
2799 @end deffn
2800
2801 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2802 Display either the address of the I/O port
2803 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2804 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2805 This is a write-once setting.
2806
2807 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2808 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2809 you may encounter a problem.
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2813 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2814 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2815 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2816 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2817 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2818
2819 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2820 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2821 @quotation Tip
2822 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2823 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2824 @example
2825 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2826 > adapter_khz 500
2827 @end example
2828 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2829 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2830 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2831 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2832 large set of samples.
2833 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2834 @example
2835 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2836 @end example
2837 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2838 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2839
2840 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2841 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2842 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2843 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2844 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2845 @end quotation
2846 @end deffn
2847
2848 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2849 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2850 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2851 @end deffn
2852
2853 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2854 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2855
2856 @example
2857 interface parport
2858 parport_port 0x278
2859 parport_cable wiggler
2860 @end example
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2864 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2866 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2871 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2875 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2876 @end deffn
2877
2878 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2879 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2880
2881 @quotation Note
2882 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2883 which are not currently documented here.
2884 @end quotation
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @anchor{hla_interface}
2888 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2889 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2890 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2891 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2892
2893 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2894 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2895 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2896 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2897 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2900 Currently Not Supported.
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2904 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2905 @end deffn
2906
2907 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2908 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2909 @end deffn
2910
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2912 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2916 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2917 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2922 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2926 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2930 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @quotation Note
2934 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2935 which are not currently documented here.
2936 @end quotation
2937
2938 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2939 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2940 No arguments: print status.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2944 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2945 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2946
2947 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2948 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2949 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2950 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2951 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2952 configuration on exit.
2953
2954 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2955 pinout.
2956
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @section Transport Configuration
2960 @cindex Transport
2961 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2962 and the debug adapter you are using,
2963 several transports may be available to
2964 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2965 @deffn Command {transport list}
2966 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2967 version of OpenOCD.
2968 @end deffn
2969
2970 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2971 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2972
2973 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2974 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2975 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2976 adapter's driver).
2977
2978 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2979 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2980 supported by the debug adapter.
2981
2982 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2983 transport, if any.
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @subsection JTAG Transport
2987 @cindex JTAG
2988 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2989 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2990 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2991 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2992 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2993 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2994
2995 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2996 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2997 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2998 hla_jtag}.
2999
3000 @subsection SWD Transport
3001 @cindex SWD
3002 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3003 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3004 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3005 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3006 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3007 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3008 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3009
3010 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3011 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3012 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3013 hla_swd}.
3014
3015 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3016 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3017 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3018 expected to change.
3019 @end deffn
3020 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3021 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3022 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3023 No parameters: displays current settings.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @subsection SPI Transport
3027 @cindex SPI
3028 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3029 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3030 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3031 solution for flash programming.
3032
3033 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3034 @section JTAG Speed
3035 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3036 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3037 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3038 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3039 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3040 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3041 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3042 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3043 power management software that may be active.
3044
3045 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3046 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3047 target event handler.
3048 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3049 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3050 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3051 sets up those clocks).
3052 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3053 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3054 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3055 in the target config file.
3056 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3057 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3058 config file instead.
3059 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3060 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3061 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3062
3063 @example
3064 jtag_rclk 3000
3065 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3066 @end example
3067
3068 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3069 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3070 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3071 may not be the fastest solution.
3072
3073 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3074 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3075 which support adaptive clocking.
3076
3077 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3078 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3079 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3080 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3081 than the speed specified.
3082
3083 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3084 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3085 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3086 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3087
3088 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3089 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3090 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3091 JTAG clocking after setup.
3092 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3093 If the interface device can not
3094 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3098 @cindex adaptive clocking
3099 @cindex RTCK
3100 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3101 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3102 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3103 @example
3104 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3105 jtag_rclk 3000
3106 @end example
3107 @end defun
3108
3109 @node Reset Configuration
3110 @chapter Reset Configuration
3111 @cindex Reset Configuration
3112
3113 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3114 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3115 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3116 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3117 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3118 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3119 Please see the various board files for examples.
3120
3121 @quotation Note
3122 To maintainers and integrators:
3123 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3124 Normally the board configuration file
3125 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3126 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3127
3128 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3129 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3130 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3131 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3132 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3133 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3134 @end quotation
3135
3136 @section Types of Reset
3137
3138 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3139 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3140 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3141
3142 @itemize @bullet
3143 @item
3144 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3145 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3146 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3147 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3148 @item
3149 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3150 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3151 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3152 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3153 @item
3154 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3155 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3156 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3157 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3158 @item
3159 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3160 several other types of reset.
3161 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3162 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3163 There may be individual module resets.
3164 @end itemize
3165
3166 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3167 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3168 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3169 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3170 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3171 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3172 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3173 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3174 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3175
3176 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3177 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3178
3179 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3180 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3181 common issues are:
3182
3183 @itemize @bullet
3184
3185 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3186 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3187 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3188 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3189 when either of those signals is not connected.
3190 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3191 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3192 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3193 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3194
3195 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3196 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3197 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3198 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3199
3200 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3201 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3202 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3203 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3204 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3205 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3206 hardware debouncing.
3207 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3208 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3209
3210 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3211 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3212 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3213 to use push/pull output drivers.
3214 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3215 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3216 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3217 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3218
3219 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3220 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3221 issues (not limited to errata).
3222 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3223 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3224 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3225 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3226 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3227 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3228 @end itemize
3229
3230 There can also be other issues.
3231 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3232 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3233 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3234 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3235 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3236 Agreement (NDA).
3237
3238 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3239 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3240 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3241
3242 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3243 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3244
3245 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3246
3247 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3248 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3249 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3250 allowing it to be deasserted.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3254 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3255 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3256 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3257 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3261 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3262 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3263 allowing it to be deasserted.
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3267 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3268 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3272 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3273 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3274 configuration scripts.
3275
3276 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3277 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3278 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3279 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3280 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3281 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3282 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3283 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3284
3285 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3286 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3287 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3288 -- may be specified at a time.
3289 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3290 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3291 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3292 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3293 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3294
3295 @itemize
3296 @item
3297 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3298 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3299 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3300 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3301 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3302
3303 @quotation Tip
3304 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3305 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3306 @end quotation
3307
3308 @item
3309 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3310 signal implementations.
3311 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3312 indicating everything behaves normally.
3313 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3314 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3315 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3316 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3317 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3318 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3319 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3320
3321 @item
3322 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3323 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3324 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3325 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3326 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3327 while SRST is asserted.
3328 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3329 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3330
3331 @item
3332 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3333 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3334 is required to use this option.
3335 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3336 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3337 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3338 be asserted before any target connection.
3339 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3340 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3341 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3342 @end itemize
3343
3344 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3345 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3346 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3347 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3348 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3349
3350 @itemize
3351 @item
3352 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3353 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3354 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3355 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3356
3357 @item
3358 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3359 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3360 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3361 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3362 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3363 @end itemize
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @section Custom Reset Handling
3367 @cindex events
3368
3369 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3370 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3371 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3372 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3373 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3374 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3375
3376 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3377 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3378 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3379 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3380 want to reset everything at once.
3381
3382 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3383 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3384 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3385 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3386 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3387 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3388 needs special attention.
3389
3390 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3391 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3392 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3393 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3394 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3395 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3396 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3397 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3398
3399 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3400 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3401 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3402 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3403 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3404
3405 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3406 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3407 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3408 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3409 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3410 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3411 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3412 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3413 or potentially some other value.
3414
3415 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3416 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3417 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3418 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3419 (or their associated targets)
3420 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3421
3422 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3423 they return.
3424 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3425 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3429 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3430 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3431 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3432 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3433 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3434 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3435 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3436 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3437 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3438 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3439 @end deffn
3440
3441 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3442 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3443 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3444 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3445 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3446 @end deffn
3447
3448
3449 @node TAP Declaration
3450 @chapter TAP Declaration
3451 @cindex TAP declaration
3452 @cindex TAP configuration
3453
3454 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3455 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3456
3457 @itemize @bullet
3458 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3459 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3460 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3461 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3462 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3463 start running that code.
3464 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3465 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3466 and missing connections.
3467 @end itemize
3468
3469 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3470 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3471 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3472 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3473 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3474
3475 @section Scan Chains
3476 @cindex scan chain
3477
3478 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3479 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3480 They also need to be added to
3481 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3482 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3483 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3484 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3485 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3486 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3487 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3488 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3489
3490 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3491 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3492 command, presented in the next chapter.
3493 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3494 debugging targets.)
3495 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3496
3497 @verbatim
3498 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3499 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3500 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3501 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3502 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3503 @end verbatim
3504
3505 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3506 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3507 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3508 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3509 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3510 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3511 until they are told to do so.
3512
3513 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3514 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3515 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3516 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3517
3518 @example
3519 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3520 @end example
3521
3522 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3523 by a given chip.
3524 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3525 and so forth.
3526 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3527 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3528 both inside a single chip and between them.
3529 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3530
3531 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3532 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3533 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3534 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3535 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3536 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3537 includes commands something like this:
3538
3539 @example
3540 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3541 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3542 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3543 @end example
3544
3545 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3546 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3547 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3548
3549 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3550 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3551 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3552 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3553 @example
3554 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3555 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3556 @}
3557 @end example
3558 @end deffn
3559
3560 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3561 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3562 and their status.
3563 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3564 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3565 but systems with a JTAG router can
3566 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3570 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3571
3572 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3573 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3574
3575 @section TAP Names
3576 @cindex dotted name
3577
3578 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3579 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3580 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3581 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3582 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3583 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3584 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3585 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3586
3587 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3588 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3589 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3590
3591 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3592
3593 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3594 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3595 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3596 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3597
3598 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3599 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3600 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3601 overridable.
3602
3603 @cindex TAP naming convention
3604 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3605 and should follow this convention:
3606
3607 @itemize @bullet
3608 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3609 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3610 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3611 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3612 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3613 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3614 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3615 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3616 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3617 with a single TAP;
3618 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3619 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3620 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3621 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3622 @end itemize
3623
3624 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3625
3626 @itemize @bullet
3627 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3628 @*The length in bits of the
3629 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3630 @end itemize
3631
3632 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3633
3634 @itemize @bullet
3635 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3636 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3637 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3638 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3639 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3640 (the TAP is linked in).
3641 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3642 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3643 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3644 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3645 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3646 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3647 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3648 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3649 values that were found but not included in the list.
3650
3651 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3652 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3653 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3654 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3655 hardware to find these values.
3656 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3657 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3658 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3659 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3660 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3661 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3662 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3663 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3664 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3665 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3666 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3667 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3668 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3669 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3670 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3671 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3672 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3673 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3674 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3675 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3676 @end itemize
3677 @end deffn
3678
3679 @section Other TAP commands
3680
3681 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3682 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3683 At this writing this TAP attribute
3684 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3685 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3686 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3687 See the next section for information about the available events.
3688
3689 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3690 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3691 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3692 @end deffn
3693
3694 @section TAP Events
3695 @cindex events
3696 @cindex TAP events
3697
3698 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3699 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3700 The other applies to debugger targets,
3701 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3702
3703 The TAP events currently defined are:
3704
3705 @itemize @bullet
3706 @item @b{post-reset}
3707 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3708 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3709 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3710 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3711 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3712
3713 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3714 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3715 of any particular target.
3716 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3717 @item @b{setup}
3718 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3719 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3720 @item @b{tap-disable}
3721 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3722 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3723 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3724 @item @b{tap-enable}
3725 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3726 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3727 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3731 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3732 contents to be accurate), you might:
3733
3734 @example
3735 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3736 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3737 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3738 @}
3739 @end example
3740
3741
3742 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3743 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3744 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3745 @cindex jrc
3746
3747 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3748 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3749 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3750 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3751 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3752
3753 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3754 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3755 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3756 be visible.
3757 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3758 ignores, such as:
3759
3760 @itemize
3761 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3762 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3763 TAPs receive new instructions.
3764 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3765 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3766 @end itemize
3767
3768 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3769 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3770 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3771 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3772
3773 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3774 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3775
3776 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3777 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3778 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3779 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3780 should define TAP event handlers using
3781 code that looks something like this:
3782
3783 @example
3784 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3785 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3786 @}
3787 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3788 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3789 @}
3790 @end example
3791
3792 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3793
3794 @example
3795 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3796 @end example
3797
3798 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3799 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3800 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3801 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3802
3803 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3804 If necessary, disables the tap
3805 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3806 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3807 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3808 and "0" if it is disabled.
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3812 If necessary, enables the tap
3813 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3814 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3815 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3816 and "0" if it is disabled.
3817 @end deffn
3818
3819 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3820 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3821 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3822 and "0" if it is disabled.
3823
3824 @quotation Note
3825 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3826 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3827 @end quotation
3828 @end deffn
3829
3830 @anchor{autoprobing}
3831 @section Autoprobing
3832 @cindex autoprobe
3833 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3834
3835 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3836 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3837 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3838 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3839
3840 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3841 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3842 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3843 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3844 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3845 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3846 right when they come out of reset).
3847
3848 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3849
3850 @example
3851 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3852 reset_config trst_and_srst
3853 jtag_rclk 8
3854 @end example
3855
3856 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3857 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3858
3859 @enumerate
3860 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3861 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3862 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3863 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3864 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3865 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3866 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3867 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3868 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3869 that is discovered.
3870 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3871 register, it will report it.
3872 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3873 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3874 @end enumerate
3875
3876 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3877 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3878 that's a bit more complex:
3879
3880 @example
3881 clock speed 8 kHz
3882 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3883 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3884 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3885 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3886 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3887 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3888 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3889 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3890 @end example
3891
3892 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3893 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3894 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3895 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3896 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3897 and so forth.
3898
3899 @node CPU Configuration
3900 @chapter CPU Configuration
3901 @cindex GDB target
3902
3903 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3904 You can also access these targets without GDB
3905 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3906 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3907 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3908 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3909
3910 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3911 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3912
3913 @section Target List
3914 @cindex target, current
3915 @cindex target, list
3916
3917 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3918 where each member has a name.
3919 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3920 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3921 (plural!) command.
3922 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3923 look like with more than one:
3924 @verbatim
3925 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3926 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3927 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3928 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3929 @end verbatim
3930
3931 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3932 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3933 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3934 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3935 space seen by that current target.
3936 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3937 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3938 are examples; and there are many more.
3939
3940 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3941
3942 @deffn Command {target current}
3943 Returns the name of the current target.
3944 @end deffn
3945
3946 @deffn Command {target names}
3947 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3948 @example
3949 foreach t [target names] @{
3950 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3951 @}
3952 @end example
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3956 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3957
3958 @deffn Command targets [name]
3959 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3960 command names are singular.}
3961
3962 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3963 targets in a user friendly form.
3964
3965 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3966 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3967 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3968 @end deffn
3969
3970 @section Target CPU Types
3971 @cindex target type
3972 @cindex CPU type
3973
3974 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3975 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3976 when calling @command{target create}.
3977 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3978 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3979 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3980 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3981 what core-specific commands may be available
3982 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3983 and more.
3984
3985 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3986 since there's a command to list them.
3987
3988 @anchor{targettypes}
3989 @deffn Command {target types}
3990 Lists all supported target types.
3991 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3992
3993 @itemize @bullet
3994 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3995 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3996 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3997 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3998 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3999 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4000 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4001 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4002 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4003 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4004 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4005 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4006 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4007 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4008 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4009 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4010 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4011 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4012 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4013 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4014 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4015 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4016 @itemize @minus
4017 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4018 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4019 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4020 @end itemize
4021 And two debug interfaces cores:
4022 @itemize @minus
4023 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4024 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4025 @end itemize
4026 @end itemize
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4030 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4031 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4032 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4033 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4034 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4035 reflect design generations;
4036 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4037 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4038
4039 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4040 @section Target Configuration
4041
4042 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4043 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4044 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4045 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4046 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4047
4048 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4049 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4050 optional parts.
4051 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4052 command, created as part of target creation.
4053
4054 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4055 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4056 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4057 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4058 to be much more board-specific.
4059 The key steps you use might look something like this
4060
4061 @example
4062 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4063 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4064 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4065 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4066 @end example
4067
4068 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4069 on-chip SRAM.
4070 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4071 writes to target memory;
4072 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4073 GDB memory checksumming;
4074 and more.
4075
4076 @quotation Warning
4077 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4078 inaccessible when application code
4079 (such as an operating system)
4080 enables or disables the MMU.
4081 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4082 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4083 easy access to other addresses needed.
4084 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4085 @end quotation
4086
4087 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4088 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4089 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4090 controllers.
4091 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4092 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4093 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4094
4095 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4096 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4097 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4098 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4099 purposes including additional configuration.
4100
4101 @itemize @bullet
4102 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4103 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4104 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4105 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4106
4107 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4108 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4109 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4110 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4111 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4112 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4113 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4114
4115 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4116 @end itemize
4117 @end deffn
4118
4119 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4120 The options accepted by this command may also be
4121 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4122 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4123 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4124
4125 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4126 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4127 and changing its endianness.
4128
4129 @itemize @bullet
4130
4131 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4132 used to access this target.
4133
4134 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4135 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4136
4137 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4138 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4139 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4140 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4141 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4142 same event name assigns only one handler.
4143
4144 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4145 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4146 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4147 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4148 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4149 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4150 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4151
4152 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4153 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4154 or virtual address is being used.
4155
4156 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4157 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4158
4159 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4160 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4161 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4162 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4163 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4164
4165 @anchor{rtostype}
4166 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4167 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4168 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4169 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4170
4171 @end itemize
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @section Other $target_name Commands
4175 @cindex object command
4176
4177 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4178 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4179
4180 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4181 Once a button is created a button
4182 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4183 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4184 configure it like this:
4185
4186 @example
4187 # Create
4188 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4189 # Modify
4190 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4191 # Query
4192 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4193 # Report
4194 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4195 @end example
4196
4197 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4198 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4199
4200 @example
4201 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4202 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4203 @end example
4204
4205 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4206
4207 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4208 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4209 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4210 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4211 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4212 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4213 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4214 They are not otherwise documented here.
4215 @end deffn
4216
4217 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4218 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4219 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4220 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4221 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4222 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4223 the target side uses raw memory.
4224
4225 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4226 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4227 The script orientation comes from working with data
4228 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4229 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4230 and neither store nor return those values.
4231
4232 @itemize
4233 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4234 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4235 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4236 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4237 @end itemize
4238 @end deffn
4239
4240 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4241 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4242 @command{$target_name configure}
4243 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4244 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4245 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4246 There are a few special cases:
4247
4248 @itemize @bullet
4249 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4250 event named @var{event_name}.
4251 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4252 two parameters.
4253 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4254 This is a special case because this is set using
4255 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4256 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4257 @end itemize
4258
4259 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4260 all the targets you might use something like this:
4261
4262 @example
4263 foreach name [target names] @{
4264 set y [$name cget -endian]
4265 set z [$name cget -type]
4266 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4267 $x $name $y $z]
4268 @}
4269 @end example
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4273 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4274 Displays the current target state:
4275 @code{debug-running},
4276 @code{halted},
4277 @code{reset},
4278 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4279 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4280 @end deffn
4281
4282 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4283 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4284 currently associated with this target.
4285 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4289 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4290 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4291 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4295 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4296 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4297 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4298 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4299 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4300 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4301 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4302 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4307 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4308 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4309 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4310 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @anchor{targetevents}
4314 @section Target Events
4315 @cindex target events
4316 @cindex events
4317 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4318 For example:
4319 @itemize @bullet
4320 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4321 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4322 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4323 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4324 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4325 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4326 to set up system clocks or
4327 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4328 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4329 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4330 @end itemize
4331
4332 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4333 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4334 @command{target create ... -event}.
4335
4336 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4337 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4338 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4339
4340 @example
4341 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4342 echo "Reset..."
4343 reset halt
4344 @}
4345 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4346 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4347 echo "Reset..."
4348 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4349 # we need a reset init.
4350 reset init
4351 @}
4352 @end example
4353
4354 The following target events are defined:
4355
4356 @itemize @bullet
4357 @item @b{debug-halted}
4358 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4359 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4360 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4361 @item @b{early-halted}
4362 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4363 @item @b{examine-start}
4364 @* Before target examine is called.
4365 @item @b{examine-end}
4366 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4367 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4368 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4369 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4370 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4371 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4372 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4373 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4374 @* When GDB disconnects
4375 @item @b{gdb-end}
4376 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4377 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4378 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4379 @code{reset init})
4380 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4381 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4382 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4383 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4384 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4385 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4386 @item @b{gdb-start}
4387 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4388 @item @b{halted}
4389 @* The target has halted
4390 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4391 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4392 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4393 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4394 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4395 @item @b{reset-assert}
4396 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4397 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4398 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4399 it instead of asserting SRST.
4400 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4401 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4402 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4403 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4404 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4405 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4406 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4407 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4408 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4409 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4410 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4411 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4412 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4413 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4414 released on the scan chain.
4415 @item @b{reset-end}
4416 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4417 @ignore
4418 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4419 @* Currently not used
4420 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4421 @* Currently not used
4422 @end ignore
4423 @item @b{reset-init}
4424 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4425 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4426
4427 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4428 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4429 multiplexing, and so on.
4430 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4431 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4432 @item @b{reset-start}
4433 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4434 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4435
4436 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4437 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4438 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4439 @ignore
4440 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4441 @* Currently not used
4442 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4443 @* Currently not used
4444 @end ignore
4445 @item @b{resume-start}
4446 @* Before any target is resumed
4447 @item @b{resume-end}
4448 @* After all targets have resumed
4449 @item @b{resumed}
4450 @* Target has resumed
4451 @item @b{trace-config}
4452 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4453 @end itemize
4454
4455 @node Flash Commands
4456 @chapter Flash Commands
4457
4458 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4459 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4460 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4461 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4462 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4463 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4464 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4465 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4466 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4467
4468 Flash Steps:
4469 @enumerate
4470 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4471 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4472 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4473 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4474 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4475 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4476 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4477 @item GDB Flashing
4478 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4479 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4480 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4481 @end enumerate
4482
4483 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4484 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4485 so that it can't boot.
4486 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4487 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4488
4489 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4490 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4491 @cindex flash configuration
4492
4493 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4494 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4495 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4496 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4497 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4498 see the driver-specific documentation.
4499
4500 @itemize @bullet
4501 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4502 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4503 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4504 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4505 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4506 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4507 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4508 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4509 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4510 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4511 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4512 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4513 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4514 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4515 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4516 commands to the flash controller.
4517 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4518 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4519 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4520 for more information.
4521 @end itemize
4522 @quotation Note
4523 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4524 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4525 @end quotation
4526 @end deffn
4527
4528 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4529 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4530 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4531 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4532 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4533 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4534 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4535 @end deffn
4536
4537 @deffn Command {flash list}
4538 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4539 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4540 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4541 @end deffn
4542
4543 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4544 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4545 depends on the flash type.
4546 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4547 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4548 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4549 but most don't bother.
4550 @end deffn
4551
4552 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4553 @cindex flash erasing
4554 @cindex flash reading
4555 @cindex flash writing
4556 @cindex flash programming
4557 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4558
4559 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4560 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4561 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4562 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4563 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4564
4565 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4566 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4567 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4568 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4569 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4570
4571 @quotation Note
4572 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4573 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4574 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4575 back to a flash bank.
4576 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4577 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4578 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4579 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4580 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4581 @end quotation
4582
4583 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4584 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4585 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4586 disabled first.
4587 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4588 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4589 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4590
4591 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4592 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4593 up to and including @var{last}.
4594 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4595 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4596 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4597 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4598 @end deffn
4599
4600 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4601 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4602 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4603 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4604 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4605 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4606 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4607 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4608 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4609 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4610 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4611 before erase starts.
4612 @end deffn
4613
4614 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4615 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4616 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4617 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4618 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4619 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4620 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4621 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4622 before issuing this command.
4623 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4624 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4625 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4626 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4627 @end deffn
4628 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4629
4630 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4631 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4632 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4633 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4634 @end deffn
4635
4636 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4637 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4638 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4639 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4640 to the base address for each section in the image.
4641 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4642 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4643 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4644 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4645 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4646 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4647 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4648 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4649 each image section.
4650
4651 @quotation Warning
4652 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4653 data you want to preserve.
4654 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4655 sections might be erased with no notice.
4656 @itemize
4657 @item
4658 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4659 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4660 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4661 @item
4662 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4663 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4664 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4665 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4666 @end itemize
4667 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4668 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4669 @end quotation
4670
4671 @end deffn
4672
4673 @section Other Flash commands
4674 @cindex flash protection
4675
4676 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4677 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4678 and display that status.
4679 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4683 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4684 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4685 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4686 and possibly stale information.
4687 @end deffn
4688
4689 @anchor{flashprotect}
4690 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4691 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4692 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4693 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4694 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4695 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4696 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4697 @end deffn
4698
4699 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4700 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4701 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4702 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4703 @end deffn
4704
4705 @anchor{program}
4706 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4707 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4708 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4709 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4710 @end deffn
4711
4712 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4713 @section Flash Driver List
4714 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4715 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4716 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4717
4718 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4719 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4720 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4721
4722 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4723
4724 @itemize
4725 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4726 @end itemize
4727
4728 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4729 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4730 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4731 @example
4732 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4733 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4734 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4735 @end example
4736 @end deffn
4737
4738 @subsection External Flash
4739
4740 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4741 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4742 @cindex CFI
4743 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4744 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4745 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4746 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4747 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4748 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4749 configure a bus and its timings), or
4750 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4751 on the flash chip.
4752 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4753 speed up operation.
4754
4755 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4756
4757 @itemize
4758 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4759 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4760 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4761 @end itemize
4762
4763 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4764 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4765
4766 @example
4767 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4769 @end example
4770
4771 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4772 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4773 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4774
4775 @example
4776 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4777 @end example
4778
4779 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4780 @end deffn
4781
4782 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4783 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4784 @cindex SPIFI
4785 @cindex lpcspifi
4786 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4787 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4788 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4789
4790 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4791 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4792 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4793 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4794 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4795
4796 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4797 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4798 are configured by the driver.
4799
4800 @example
4801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4802 @end example
4803
4804 @end deffn
4805
4806 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4807 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4808 @cindex SMI
4809 @cindex stmsmi
4810 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4811 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4812 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4813 SPI flash devices.
4814 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4815 flash devices can be connected.
4816
4817 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4818 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4819 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4820 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4821 the flash content.
4822
4823 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4824 to identify the memory bank.
4825 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4826 flash size, are detected automatically.
4827
4828 @example
4829 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4830 @end example
4831
4832 @end deffn
4833
4834 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4835 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4836 Microcontroller platform.
4837
4838 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4839 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4840
4841 @example
4842 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4843 @end example
4844
4845 @end deffn
4846
4847 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4848
4849 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4850 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4851 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4852 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4853 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4854 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4855
4856 @example
4857 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4858 @end example
4859 @end deffn
4860
4861 @anchor{at91samd}
4862 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4863 @cindex at91samd
4864
4865 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4866 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4867 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4868 processor to be halted.
4869 @end deffn
4870
4871 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4872 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4873 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4874 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4875 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4876 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4877
4878 @example
4879 at91samd set-security enable
4880 @end example
4881 @end deffn
4882
4883 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4884 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4885 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4886 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4887 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4888 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4889 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4890 in order to disable this feature.
4891
4892 @example
4893 at91samd eeprom
4894 at91samd eeprom 1024
4895 @end example
4896 @end deffn
4897
4898 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4899 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4900 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4901 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4902 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4903 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4904
4905 @example
4906 at91samd bootloader
4907 at91samd bootloader 16384
4908 @end example
4909 @end deffn
4910
4911 @end deffn
4912
4913 @anchor{at91sam3}
4914 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4915 @cindex at91sam3
4916 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4917 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4918 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4919 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4920 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4921 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4922 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4923 chips are confirmed.}
4924
4925 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4926 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4927 the following fixed locations:
4928
4929 @example
4930 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
4931 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4932 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
4933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4934 @end example
4935
4936 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
4937 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
4938 to the @command{flash bank} command:
4939
4940 @itemize
4941 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
4942 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
4943 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
4944 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
4945 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
4946 @end itemize
4947
4948 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
4949
4950 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
4951 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
4952 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
4953 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
4954 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
4955 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
4956 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
4957
4958 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
4959 modifies that GPNVM bit.
4960 @end deffn
4961
4962 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
4963 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
4964 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
4965 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
4966 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
4967 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
4968 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
4969 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
4970 @end deffn
4971
4972 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
4973 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
4974 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
4975 @end deffn
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
4979 @cindex at91sam4
4980 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
4981 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4982 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
4986 @cindex at91sam4l
4987 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
4988 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4989 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4990
4991 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
4992 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
4993 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
4994 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4995 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4996 @end deffn
4997 @end deffn
4998
4999 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5000 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5001 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5002 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5003 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5004
5005 @example
5006 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5007 @end example
5008
5009 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5010 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5011
5012 @itemize
5013 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5014 @item @var{banks}
5015 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5016 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5017 @item @var{pages_size}
5018 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5019 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5020 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5021 @end itemize
5022
5023 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5024 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5025 will be autoconfigured.
5026 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5027
5028 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5029 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5030 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5031 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5032 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5033
5034 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5035 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5036 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5037 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5038 are not truly general purpose).
5039 @quotation Note
5040 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5041 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5042 @end quotation
5043 @end deffn
5044 @end deffn
5045
5046 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5047 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5048 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5049 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5050 @end deffn
5051
5052 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5053 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5054 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5055 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5056 autoconfigures itself.
5057 @example
5058 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5059 @end example
5060 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5061 supported.}
5062 @end deffn
5063
5064 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5065 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5066 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5067 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5068 microcontroller families from NXP.
5069
5070 @quotation Note
5071 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5072 driver:
5073 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5074 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5075 @end quotation
5076
5077 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5078 which must appear in the following order:
5079
5080 @itemize
5081 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5082 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5083 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5084 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5085 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5086 LPC43x[2357])
5087 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5088 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5089 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5090 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5091 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5092 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5093 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5094 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5095 at which the core is running
5096 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5097 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5098 @quotation Note
5099 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5100 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5101 However, if you do provide it,
5102 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5103 @end quotation
5104 @end itemize
5105
5106 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5107
5108 @example
5109 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5110 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5111 @end example
5112
5113 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5114 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5115 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5116 @end deffn
5117 @end deffn
5118
5119 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5120 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5121 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5122 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5123 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5124 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5125
5126 @example
5127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5128 @end example
5129 @end deffn
5130
5131 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5132 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5133 from NXP.
5134
5135 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5136 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5137 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5138 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5139 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5140 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5141 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5142 you start the PLL.
5143
5144 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5145
5146 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5147 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5148 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5149
5150 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5151 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5152 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5153 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5154 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5155 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5156 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5157
5158 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5159 @example
5160 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5161 @end example
5162
5163 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5164 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5165 @code{flash banks} command.
5166
5167 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5168 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5169 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5170 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5171 a known signature.
5172 Example:
5173 @example
5174 lpc2900 signature 0
5175 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5176 @end example
5177 @end deffn
5178
5179 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5180 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5181 saves it to a file in binary format.
5182 Example:
5183 @example
5184 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5185 @end example
5186 @end deffn
5187
5188 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5189 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5190 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5191 command:
5192
5193 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5194 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5195 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5196 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5197
5198 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5199 Example:
5200 @example
5201 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5202 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5203 @end example
5204 @end deffn
5205
5206 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5207 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5208 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5209 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5210 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5211 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5212 912 bytes.
5213 @quotation Attention
5214 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5215 @end quotation
5216 Example:
5217 @example
5218 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5219 @end example
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5223 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5224 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5225 after the next power cycle.
5226 @quotation Attention
5227 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5228 @end quotation
5229 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5230 Example:
5231 @example
5232 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5233 flash info 0
5234 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5235 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5236 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5237 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5238 @end example
5239 @end deffn
5240
5241 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5242 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5243 effective after the next power cycle.
5244 @quotation Attention
5245 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5246 @end quotation
5247 Examples:
5248 @example
5249 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5250 @end example
5251 @end deffn
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5255 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5256 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5257
5258 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5259 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5260 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5261 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5262
5263 @example
5264 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5265 @end example
5266 @end deffn
5267
5268 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5269 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5270 and integrate flash memory.
5271
5272 @example
5273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5274 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5275 @end example
5276
5277 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5278 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5279 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5280 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5281 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5282 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5283 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5284 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5285 @end deffn
5286 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5287 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5288 This will remove any Code Protection.
5289 @end deffn
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5293 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5294 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5295 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5296 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5297
5298 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5299 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5300
5301 @example
5302 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5303 @end example
5304
5305 psoc4-specific commands
5306 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5307 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5308
5309 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5310 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5311
5312 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5313 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5314 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5315
5316 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5317 @end deffn
5318
5319 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5320 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5321
5322 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5323 @end deffn
5324 @end deffn
5325
5326 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5327 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5328 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5329 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5330 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5331 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5332 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5333 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5334
5335 @example
5336 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5337 @end example
5338
5339 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5340 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5341 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5342 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5343 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5344 disabled.
5345
5346 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5347 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5348 @quotation Warning
5349 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5350 applied to all of them.
5351 @end quotation
5352 @end deffn
5353 @end deffn
5354
5355 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5356 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5357 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5358 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5359 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5360
5361 @example
5362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5363 @end example
5364
5365 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5366 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5367 the flash driver.
5368
5369 @example
5370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5371 @end example
5372
5373 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5374 as per the following example.
5375 @example
5376 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5377 @end example
5378
5379 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5380 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5381 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5382 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5383 are defined:
5384
5385 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5386 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5387 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5388 @end deffn
5389
5390 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5391 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5392 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5396 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5397 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5398 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5399 @end deffn
5400
5401 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5402 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5403 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5404 @end deffn
5405 @end deffn
5406
5407 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5408 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5409 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5410 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5411 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5412
5413 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5414 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5415 the flash driver.
5416
5417 @example
5418 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5419 @end example
5420
5421 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5422
5423 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5424 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5425 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5426 @end deffn
5427
5428 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5429 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5430 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5431 @end deffn
5432 @end deffn
5433
5434 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5435 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5436 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5437 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5438 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5439
5440 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5441 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5442 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5443 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5444 second bank.
5445
5446 @example
5447 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5448 @end example
5449
5450 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5451
5452 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5453 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5454 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5455 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5456 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5457 @end deffn
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5461 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5462 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5463 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5464 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5465
5466 @example
5467 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5468 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5469 @end example
5470
5471 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5472 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5473 for the specified flash bank.
5474 @end deffn
5475 @end deffn
5476
5477 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5478 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5479 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5480 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5481 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5482
5483 @example
5484 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5485 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5486 @end example
5487
5488 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5489 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5490 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5491
5492 @itemize @bullet
5493 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5494 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5495 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5496 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5497 @end itemize
5498 @end deffn
5499
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5503 @cindex str9xpec
5504
5505 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5506 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5507 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5508 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5509
5510 Here is some background info to help
5511 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5512 the str9:
5513 @enumerate
5514 @item
5515 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5516 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5517 @item
5518 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5519 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5520 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5521 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5522 @end enumerate
5523
5524 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5525 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5526 configured for flash bank 0.
5527 @example
5528 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5529 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5530 jtag_reset 0 1
5531 # turn off target polling
5532 poll off
5533 # disable str9 core
5534 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5535 # read option bytes
5536 str9xpec options_read 0
5537 # re-enable str9 core
5538 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5539 poll on
5540 reset halt
5541 @end example
5542 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5543 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5544 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5545 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5546
5547 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5548
5549 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5550 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5551 @end deffn
5552
5553 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5554 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5555 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5556 @end deffn
5557
5558 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5559 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5560 erase the device.
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5564 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5568 Configure str9 boot bank.
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5572 Configure str9 lvd source.
5573 @end deffn
5574
5575 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5576 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5577 @end deffn
5578
5579 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5580 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5581 @end deffn
5582
5583 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5584 Read str9 option bytes.
5585 @end deffn
5586
5587 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5588 Write str9 option bytes.
5589 @end deffn
5590
5591 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5592 unlock str9 device.
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5598 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5599 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5600 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5601
5602 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5603
5604 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5605 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5606 @end deffn
5607
5608 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5609 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5610 @end deffn
5611
5612 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5613 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5614 the flash clock.
5615 @end deffn
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5619 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5620 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5621 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5622 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5623 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5624 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5625
5626 @example
5627 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5628 @end example
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5632 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5633 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5634 and SWD interface.
5635 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5636 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5637
5638 @example
5639 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5640 @end example
5641
5642 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5643
5644 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5645 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5646 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5650 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5651 @end deffn
5652 @end deffn
5653
5654 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5655 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5656 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5657
5658 @example
5659 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5660 @end example
5661
5662 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5663
5664 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5665 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5666 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5667 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5668 code.
5669 @end deffn
5670
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5674 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5675 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5676 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5677
5678 @example
5679 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5680 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5681 @end example
5682
5683 @itemize @bullet
5684 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5685 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5686 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5687 @end itemize
5688
5689 Example usage:
5690 @example
5691 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5692 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5693 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5694 @} else @{
5695 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5696 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5697 @}
5698 @end example
5699 @end deffn
5700
5701 @section NAND Flash Commands
5702 @cindex NAND
5703
5704 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5705 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5706 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5707
5708 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5709 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5710 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5711 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5712 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5713 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5714
5715 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5716 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5717 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5718 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5719 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5720 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5721 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5722 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5723 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5724 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5725
5726 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5727 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5728 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5729 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5730 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5731 every 512 bytes of data.
5732
5733 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5734 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5735 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5736 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5737 ECC mode is used.
5738
5739 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5740 @enumerate
5741 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5742 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5743 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5744 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5745 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5746 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5747 to access that device.
5748 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5749 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5750 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5751 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5752 de-brick a board.
5753 @end enumerate
5754
5755 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5756 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5757 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5758 are only 32 bits wide.
5759 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5760 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5761 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5762 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5763
5764 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5765 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5766 @cindex NAND configuration
5767
5768 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5769 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5770 OpenOCD has initialized.
5771
5772 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5773 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5774 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5775 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5776 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5777 they were a single (larger) device.
5778 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5779 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5780
5781 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5782 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5783 configuration files, not interactively.
5784
5785 @itemize @bullet
5786 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5787 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5788 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5789 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5790 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5791 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5792 commands to the NAND controller.
5793 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5794 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5795 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5796 for more information.
5797 @end itemize
5798 @end deffn
5799
5800 @deffn Command {nand list}
5801 Prints a summary of each device declared
5802 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5803 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5804 @example
5805 > nand list
5806 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5807 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5808 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5809 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5810 >
5811 @end example
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5815 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5816 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5817 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5818 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5819 it with most other NAND commands.
5820 @end deffn
5821
5822 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5823
5824 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5825 @cindex NAND reading
5826 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5827 starting at the specified offset.
5828 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5829
5830 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5831 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5832
5833 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5834 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5835 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5836
5837 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5838 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5839 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5840 method which handled that error correction.
5841
5842 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5843 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5844 @itemize @bullet
5845 @item no oob_* parameter
5846 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5847 @item @code{oob_raw}
5848 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5849 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5850 spare areas associated with each data page.
5851 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5852 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5853 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5854 @item @code{oob_only}
5855 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5856 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5857 spare areas associated with each data page.
5858 @end itemize
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5862 @cindex NAND erasing
5863 @cindex NAND programming
5864 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5865 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5866 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5867 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5868 If those parameters are not specified,
5869 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5870 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5871
5872 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5873 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5874 block marker.
5875 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5876 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5877 @end deffn
5878
5879 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5880 @cindex NAND writing
5881 @cindex NAND programming
5882 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5883 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5884 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5885 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5886
5887 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5888 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5889
5890 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5891 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5892 past the end of the device.
5893 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5894 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5895 if that's being written.)
5896
5897 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5898 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5899 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5900
5901 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5902 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5903 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5904 @itemize @bullet
5905 @item no oob_* parameter
5906 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5907 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
5908 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5909 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
5910 with hardware-computed ECC data.
5911 @item @code{oob_only}
5912 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
5913 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
5914 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
5915 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
5916 @item @code{oob_raw}
5917 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
5918 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
5919 un-altered OOB.
5920 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5921 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
5922 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
5923 @item @code{oob_softecc}
5924 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5925 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
5926 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
5927 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5928 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5929 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
5930 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5931 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
5932 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
5933 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5934 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5935 @end itemize
5936 @end deffn
5937
5938 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
5939 @cindex NAND verification
5940 @cindex NAND programming
5941 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
5942 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
5943 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5944
5945 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5946 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5947
5948 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5949 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
5950 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
5951 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
5952 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
5953
5954 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
5955 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
5956 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
5957
5958 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
5959 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
5960 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
5961 be removed in a future release.
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @subsection Other NAND commands
5965 @cindex NAND other commands
5966
5967 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
5968 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
5969 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
5970 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
5971 continues for @var{length} bytes.
5972 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5973 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5974 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5975
5976 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
5977 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
5978 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
5979 @end deffn
5980
5981 @deffn Command {nand info} num
5982 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5983 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
5984 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
5985 status for each block.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
5989 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
5990 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5991
5992 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
5993 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
5994 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
5995 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
5996 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
5997
5998 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
5999 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6000 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6001 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6002 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6003 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6004 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6005 @end deffn
6006
6007 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6008 @subsection NAND Driver List
6009 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6010 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6011 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6012
6013 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6014 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6015 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6016 address of the ECC controller.
6017 @example
6018 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6019 @end example
6020 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6021 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6022 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6023 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6024 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6025 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6026 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6027 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6028 @end deffn
6029 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6030 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6031 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6032 @end deffn
6033
6034 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6035 properly configured for input or output.
6036 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6037 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6038 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6039 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6040 @end deffn
6041 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6042 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6043 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6044 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6045 @end deffn
6046 @end deffn
6047
6048 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6049 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6050 chips from Texas Instruments.
6051 It takes three extra parameters:
6052 address of the NAND chip;
6053 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6054 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6055 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6056 @example
6057 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6058 @end example
6059 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6060 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6061 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6062 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6063 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6064 @end deffn
6065
6066 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6067 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6068 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6069 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6070 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6071 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6072 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6073 @end deffn
6074
6075 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6076 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6077 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6078 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6079 @end deffn
6080 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6081
6082 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6083 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6084 should work for this chip aswell.
6085 @end deffn
6086
6087 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6088 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6089 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6090 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6091 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6092 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6093 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6094 @example
6095 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6096 @end example
6097 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6098 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6099 without parameter query status.
6100 @end deffn
6101 @end deffn
6102
6103 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6104 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6105 parameter: the address of the controller.
6106 @example
6107 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6108 @end example
6109 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6110 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6111 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6112 change any behavior.
6113 @end deffn
6114
6115 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6116 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6117 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6118 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6119 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6120 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6121 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6122 specialized commands.
6123 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6124 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6125 change any behavior.
6126 @end deffn
6127
6128 @section mFlash
6129
6130 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6131 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6132
6133 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6134 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6135 address @var{base}.
6136 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6137 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6138
6139 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6140
6141 @example
6142 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6143 @end example
6144
6145 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6146
6147 @example
6148 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6149 @end example
6150 @end deffn
6151
6152 @subsection mFlash commands
6153 @cindex mFlash commands
6154
6155 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6156 Configure mflash PLL.
6157 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6158 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6159 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6160 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6161 @end deffn
6162
6163 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6164 Configure bootable option.
6165 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6166 (4kB) for boot.
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6170 Configure storage information.
6171 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6172 written.
6173 @end deffn
6174
6175 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6176 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6177 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6181 Probe mflash.
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6185 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6186 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @node Flash Programming
6190 @chapter Flash Programming
6191
6192 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6193 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6194 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6195
6196 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6197 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6198
6199 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6200 @enumerate
6201 @item 'init' is executed.
6202 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6203 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6204 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6205 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6206 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6207 @end enumerate
6208
6209 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6210
6211 @example
6212 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6213 # are optional parameters
6214 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6215 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6216
6217 # binary files need the flash address passing
6218 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6219 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6220 @end example
6221
6222 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6223 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6224 @cindex PLD
6225 @cindex FPGA
6226
6227 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6228 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6229 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6230 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6231 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6232 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6233 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6234
6235 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6236
6237 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6238 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6239 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6240
6241 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6242 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6243
6244 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6245 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6246 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6247 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6248 behavior.
6249 @end deffn
6250
6251 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6252 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6256 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6257 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6261
6262 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6263 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6264 that particular type of PLD.
6265
6266 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6267 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6268 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6269 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6270 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6271
6272 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6273 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6274 for FPGA @var{num}.
6275 @end deffn
6276 @end deffn
6277
6278 @node General Commands
6279 @chapter General Commands
6280 @cindex commands
6281
6282 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6283 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6284 commands are documented elsewhere.
6285
6286 Intent:
6287 @itemize @bullet
6288 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6289 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6290 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6291 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6292
6293 @item @b{From the human}
6294 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6295 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6296
6297 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6298 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6299 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6300
6301 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6302 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6303 port is 5555.
6304 @end itemize
6305
6306
6307 @section Daemon Commands
6308
6309 @deffn {Command} exit
6310 Exits the current telnet session.
6311 @end deffn
6312
6313 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6314 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6315 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6316 Not every command provides helptext.
6317
6318 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6319 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6320 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6321 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6325 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6326 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6327 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6328 Useful in connection with script files
6329 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6333 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6334 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6335 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @anchor{debuglevel}
6339 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6340 @cindex message level
6341 Display debug level.
6342 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6343 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6344 Level 0 is error messages only;
6345 level 1 adds warnings;
6346 level 2 adds informational messages;
6347 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6348 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6349 the command line along with the location of that log
6350 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6351 @xref{Running}.
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6355 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6356 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6357 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6358 @example
6359 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6360 @end example
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6364 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6365 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6366 @end deffn
6367
6368 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6369 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6373 @section Target State handling
6374 @cindex reset
6375 @cindex halt
6376 @cindex target initialization
6377
6378 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6379 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6380 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6381 a current target which is used to perform the
6382 various operations. The current target may be changed
6383 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6384 target which should become current.
6385
6386 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6387 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6388 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6389 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6390 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6391
6392 @emph{With no arguments}:
6393 list all available registers for the current target,
6394 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6395 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6396 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6397 are flagged as such.
6398
6399 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6400 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6401 bypassing any internal cache.
6402
6403 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6404 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6405 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6406 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6407 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6408 relevant module will flush such values.
6409
6410 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6411 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6412
6413 @example
6414 > reg
6415 ===== ARM registers
6416 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6417 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6418 (2) r2 (/32)
6419 ...
6420 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6421 >
6422 @end example
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6426 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6427 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6428 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6429 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6430 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6431 (and enter debug mode).
6432 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6433
6434 @quotation Warning
6435 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6436 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6437 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6438 power mode by gating the core clock;
6439 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6440
6441 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6442 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6443 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6444 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6445 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6446 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6447
6448 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6449 work with a JTAG debugger.
6450 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6451 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6452 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6453 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6454 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6455 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6456 @end quotation
6457
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn Command resume [address]
6461 Resume the target at its current code position,
6462 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6463 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn Command step [address]
6467 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6468 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @anchor{resetcommand}
6472 @deffn Command reset
6473 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6474 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6475 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6476 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6477 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6478 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6479
6480 The optional parameter specifies what should
6481 happen after the reset.
6482 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6483 The other options will not work on all systems.
6484 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6485
6486 @itemize @minus
6487 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6488 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6489 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6490 @end itemize
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6494 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6495 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6496 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6497 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6498 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6499 state.
6500 @end deffn
6501
6502 @section I/O Utilities
6503
6504 These commands are available when
6505 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6506 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6507 notably the ZY1000.
6508 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6509
6510 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6511
6512 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6513 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6514 the text file @file{filename}.
6515 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6516 The last string is followed by a newline.
6517 @end deffn
6518
6519 @deffn Command cat filename
6520 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6524 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6525 into @file{dest_filename}.
6526 @end deffn
6527
6528 @deffn Command ip
6529 @emph{No description provided.}
6530 @end deffn
6531
6532 @deffn Command ls
6533 @emph{No description provided.}
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn Command mac
6537 @emph{No description provided.}
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn Command meminfo
6541 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6542 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn Command peek
6546 @emph{No description provided.}
6547 @end deffn
6548
6549 @deffn Command poke
6550 @emph{No description provided.}
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn Command rm filename
6554 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6555 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn Command trunc filename
6559 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6560 @end deffn
6561
6562 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6563 @section Memory access commands
6564 @cindex memory access
6565
6566 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6567 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6568 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6569 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6570
6571 @enumerate
6572 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6573 to change the current target.
6574 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6575 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6576 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6577 @end enumerate
6578
6579 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6580 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6581 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6582 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6583 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6584 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6585 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6586 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6587 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6588 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6589 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6590 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6591 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6592 @end deffn
6593
6594 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6595 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6596 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6597 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6598 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6599 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6600 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6601 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6602 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6603 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @anchor{imageaccess}
6607 @section Image loading commands
6608 @cindex image loading
6609 @cindex image dumping
6610
6611 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6612 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6613 binary file named @var{filename}.
6614 @end deffn
6615
6616 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6617 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6618 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6622 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6623 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6624 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6625 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6626 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6627 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6628 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6629 separately.
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6633 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6634 The file format may optionally be specified
6635 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6636 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6637 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6638 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6639 @example
6640 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6641 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6642 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6643 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6644 $address $length
6645 @}
6646 @end example
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6650 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6651 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6652 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6653 The file format may optionally be specified
6654 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6658 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6659 The file format may optionally be specified
6660 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6661 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664
6665 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6666 @cindex breakpoint
6667 @cindex watchpoint
6668
6669 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6670 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6671 watchpoints.
6672 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6673
6674 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6675 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6676 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6677 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6678 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6679 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6680
6681 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6682 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6686 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6690 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6694 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6695 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6696 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6697 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6698 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6699 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6700 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6701 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6702 @end deffn
6703
6704 @section Misc Commands
6705
6706 @cindex profiling
6707 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6708 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6709 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6710 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6711 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6712 limit the address range.
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn Command {version}
6716 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6717 @end deffn
6718
6719 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6720 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6721 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6725 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6726 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6727 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6728
6729 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6730 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6731 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6732 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6733
6734 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6735 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6736 @cindex tracing
6737 @cindex ETM
6738 @cindex ETB
6739
6740 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6741 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6742 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6743
6744 @itemize
6745 @item
6746 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6747 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6748 supports such an interface.
6749 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6750 and trace port support.)
6751 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6752 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6753 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6754 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6755 in the board-specific configuration file.
6756 @item
6757 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6758 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6759 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6760 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6761 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6762 @end itemize
6763
6764 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6765
6766 @quotation Issues
6767 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6768 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6769
6770 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6771 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6772 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6773 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6774 dummy trace port driver}.
6775
6776 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6777 as well as tracing only during specific states
6778 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6779
6780 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6781 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6782 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6783 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6784 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6785
6786 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6787 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6788 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6789 this original style of JTAG access.
6790 @end quotation
6791
6792 @subsection ETM Configuration
6793 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6794
6795 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6796 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6797 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6798
6799 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6800 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6801 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6802 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6803 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6804 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6805 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6806 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6807 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6808
6809 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6810 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6811 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6812
6813 @quotation Warning
6814 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6815 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6816 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6817 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6818 @end quotation
6819
6820 @quotation Note
6821 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6822 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6823 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6824 what CPU activities are traced.
6825 @end quotation
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn Command {etm info}
6829 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6830 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6831 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6832 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6833 @end deffn
6834
6835 @deffn Command {etm status}
6836 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6837 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6838 Did trace data overflow?
6839 Was it triggered?
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6843 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6844 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6845 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6846 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6847
6848 @itemize
6849 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6850 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6851 The value is one of
6852 @option{none} (save nothing),
6853 @option{data} (save data),
6854 @option{address} (save addresses),
6855 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6856 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6857 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6858 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6859 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6860 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6861 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6862 trace stream without an image of the code.
6863 @end itemize
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6867 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6868 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6869 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6870 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6871
6872 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6873 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6874 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6878
6879 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6880 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6881 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6882
6883 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6884 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6885 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6886 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6887 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6888 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6889 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6890
6891 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6892
6893 @itemize
6894 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6895 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6896 for instruction access within that function's body.
6897 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6898 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6899 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6900 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6901 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6902 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6903 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6904 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6905 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6906 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6907 @item @emph{... more}
6908 @end itemize
6909
6910 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6911 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6912
6913 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6914 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6915 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6919 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6923 Opens an image file.
6924 @end deffn
6925
6926 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
6927 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
6928 @end deffn
6929
6930 @deffn Command {etm start}
6931 Starts trace data collection.
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 @deffn Command {etm stop}
6935 Stops trace data collection.
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
6939 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
6940
6941 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
6942
6943 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
6944 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6945 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
6946 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
6947 any trace data collection.}
6948 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
6949 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
6950 @end deffn
6951 @end deffn
6952
6953 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
6954 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
6955 to use on-chip ETB memory.
6956 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
6957 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
6958 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
6959 @end deffn
6960 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
6961 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
6962 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
6963 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
6964 trace trigger becomes active.
6965
6966 @itemize
6967 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
6968 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
6969 afterwards.
6970 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
6971 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
6972 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
6973 what caused that event to happen.
6974 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
6975 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
6976 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
6977 how the event caused trouble.
6978 @end itemize
6979 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
6980 @end deffn
6981
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
6985 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
6986 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
6987 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
6988 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
6989
6990 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6991 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
6992
6993 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
6994 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
6995 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
6999 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7000 @end deffn
7001
7002 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7003 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7004 @end deffn
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007
7008 @section Generic ARM
7009 @cindex ARM
7010
7011 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7012 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7013 commands that may be available.
7014
7015 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7016 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7017 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7018 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7019 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7020 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7024 @cindex disassemble
7025 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7026 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7027 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7028 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7029 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7030 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7031 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7032
7033 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7034 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7035 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7036 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7037 with a handful of exceptions.
7038 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7042 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7043 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7044 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7045 and using the MCR instruction.
7046 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7047 an ARM register.)
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7051 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7052 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7053 and the MRC instruction.
7054 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7055 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7056 an ARM register.)
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7060 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7061 core mode if necessary.
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7065 @cindex ARM semihosting
7066 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7067
7068 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7069 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7070 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7071 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7072 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7073 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7077 @cindex ARMv4
7078 @cindex ARMv5
7079
7080 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7081 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7082 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7083 variant.
7084
7085 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7086 @cindex ARM7
7087 @cindex ARM9
7088
7089 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7090 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7091 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7092 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7093
7094 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7095 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7096 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7097 instead of breakpoints.
7098 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7099
7100 This should be
7101 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7102 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7103 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7107 @cindex DCC
7108 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7109 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7110 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7111
7112 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7113 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7114 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7115 @end deffn
7116
7117 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7118 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7119 that don't check completion of the operation.
7120 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7121
7122 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7123 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7124 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7125 @end deffn
7126
7127 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7128 @cindex ARM720T
7129
7130 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7131 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7132 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7133 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7134
7135 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7136 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7137 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7138
7139 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7140 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7141 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7142 @end deffn
7143
7144 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7145 @cindex ARM9
7146
7147 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7148 integer processors.
7149 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7150
7151 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7152 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7153 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7154 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7155
7156 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7157 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7158 @cindex vector_catch
7159 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7160 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7161 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7162 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7163 to those hardware vectors.
7164
7165 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7166 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7167 vector catch hardware to intercept
7168 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7169 @option{none} of them,
7170 or a list with one or more of the following:
7171 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7172 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7173 @end deffn
7174
7175 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7176 @cindex ARM920T
7177
7178 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7179 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7180 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7181 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7182 and ARM9 commands.
7183
7184 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7185 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7186 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7187 @end deffn
7188
7189 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7190 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7191 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7192 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7193 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7194 (Not all registers can be written.)
7195 @end deffn
7196
7197 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7198 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7199 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7200
7201 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7202 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7203 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7204 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7205 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7206 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7210 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7214 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7215 @end deffn
7216
7217 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7218 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7219
7220 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7221 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7222 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7223 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7224 and ARM9 commands.
7225
7226 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7227 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7228
7229 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7230 Print information about the caches found.
7231 @end deffn
7232
7233 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7234 @cindex ARM966E
7235
7236 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7237 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7238 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7239 and ARM9 commands.
7240
7241 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7242 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7243 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7244 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7245 ARM966E-S TRM.
7246 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7247 as required for BIST support.
7248 @end deffn
7249
7250 @subsection XScale specific commands
7251 @cindex XScale
7252
7253 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7254
7255 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7256 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7257 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7258 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7259 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7260 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7261 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7262
7263 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7264 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7265 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7266 the mini-IC.
7267
7268 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7269 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7270 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7271 code layout in memory:
7272 @example
7273 _vectors:
7274 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7275 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7276 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7277 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7278 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7279 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7280 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7281 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7282 .org 0x100
7283 .long real_reset_vector
7284 .long real_ui_handler
7285 .long real_swi_handler
7286 .long real_pf_abort
7287 .long real_data_abort
7288 .long 0 /* unused */
7289 .long real_irq_handler
7290 .long real_fiq_handler
7291 @end example
7292
7293 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7294 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7295 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7296 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7297 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7298 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7299 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7300 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7301 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7302 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7303 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7304 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7305 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7306 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7307 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7308 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7309 software.
7310
7311 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7312 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7313 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7314 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7315
7316 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7317 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7318 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7319 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7320 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7321 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7322 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7323 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7324 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7325
7326 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7327 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7328
7329 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7330 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7331 @end deffn
7332
7333 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7334 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7338 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7339 @end deffn
7340
7341 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7342 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7343 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7347 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7351 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7355 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7359 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7363 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7367 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7368 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7369 and modifying how it is emptied.
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7373 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7374 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7375 The image @var{type} may be one of
7376 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7377 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7378 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7382 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7383 @cindex vector_catch
7384 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7385 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7386
7387 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7388 @example
7389 0x01 Trap Reset
7390 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7391 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7392 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7393 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7394 0x20 reserved
7395 0x40 Trap IRQ
7396 0x80 Trap FIQ
7397 @end example
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7401 @cindex vector_table
7402
7403 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7404 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7405 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7406 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7407 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7408
7409 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7410
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7414 @cindex ARMv6
7415
7416 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7417 @cindex ARM11
7418
7419 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7420 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7421 which is enabled by default.
7422 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7423 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7424 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7425 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7426 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7427 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7431 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7432 which is enabled by default.
7433 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7434 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7435 @end deffn
7436
7437 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7438 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7439 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7440 they are disabled by default.
7441 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7442 @end deffn
7443
7444 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7445 @cindex vector_catch
7446 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7447 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7448 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7449
7450 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7451 for certain hardware events.
7452 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7453 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7454 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7455 @end deffn
7456
7457 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7458 @cindex ARMv7
7459
7460 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7461 @cindex Debug Access Port
7462 @cindex DAP
7463 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7464 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7465 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7466
7467 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7468 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7469 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7473 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7474 @end deffn
7475
7476 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7477 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7478 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7482 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7483 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7487 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7488 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7489 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7490 @end deffn
7491
7492 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7493 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7494 Defaulting to 0.
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7498 @cindex tracing
7499 @cindex SWO
7500 @cindex SWV
7501 @cindex TPIU
7502 @cindex ITM
7503 @cindex ETM
7504
7505 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal @var{filename}}) @
7506 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7507 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7508
7509 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7510 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7511 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7512 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7513
7514 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7515 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7516 debugger adapter features.
7517
7518 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7519 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7520
7521 Command options:
7522 @itemize @minus
7523 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7524 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7525 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7526 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7527 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7528 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7529 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7530 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7531 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7532 coding;
7533 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7534 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7535 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7536 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7537 data is to be output via SWO;
7538 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7539 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7540 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7541 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7542 rate automatically.
7543 @end itemize
7544
7545 Example usage:
7546 @enumerate
7547 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7548 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7549 enough to:
7550 @example
7551 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7552 ...
7553 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7554 ...
7555 @end example
7556 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7557 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7558 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7559 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7560 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7561 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7562 @example
7563 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7564 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7565 @end example
7566 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7567 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7568 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7569 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7570 @example
7571 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7572 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7573 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7574 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7575 @end example
7576 @end enumerate
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7580 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7581 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7585 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7589 @cindex Cortex-M
7590
7591 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7592 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7593
7594 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7595 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7596 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7597 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7598 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7599 the step command leaves with the core running.
7600
7601 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7602 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7603 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7604
7605 Default is @option{auto}.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7609 @cindex vector_catch
7610 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7611 for certain hardware events.
7612
7613 Parameters request interception of
7614 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7615 @option{none} of them,
7616 or one or more of the following:
7617 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7618 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7619 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7620 @option{irq_err},
7621 @option{state_err},
7622 @option{chk_err}, or
7623 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7624 @option{reset}.
7625 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7626 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7627 are mapped to HardFault.
7628 UsageFault checks for
7629 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7630 must also be explicitly enabled.
7631
7632 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7633 @end deffn
7634
7635 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7636 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7637 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7638 @itemize @minus
7639 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7640 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7641 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7642 @end itemize
7643 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7644 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7645 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7646 the peripherals.
7647 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @section Intel Architecture
7651
7652 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7653 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7654 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7655 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7656 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7657 @itemize
7658 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7659 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7660 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7661 @end itemize
7662
7663 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7664 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7665 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7666
7667 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7668 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7672 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7676 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7677 @end deffn
7678
7679 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7680 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7681 @end deffn
7682
7683 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7684 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7685 @end deffn
7686
7687 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7688 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7689 @end deffn
7690
7691 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7692
7693 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7694 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7695
7696 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7697 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7698 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7699 @end deffn
7700 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7701 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7702
7703 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7704
7705 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7706 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7707 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7708 @end deffn
7709
7710 @subsection Registers commands
7711 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7712 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7713 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7714
7715 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7716
7717 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7718 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7719 and "timer" groups.
7720
7721 @emph{example:}
7722 @example
7723 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7724 @end example
7725
7726
7727 @end deffn
7728 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7729 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7730
7731 @emph{group} can be "system",
7732 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7733 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7734 @end deffn
7735
7736 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7737 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7738 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7739 @cindex tracing
7740 @cindex libdcc
7741 @cindex DCC
7742 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7743 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7744 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7745 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7746
7747 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7748 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7749 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7750 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7751 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7752 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7753
7754 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7755 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7756 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7757 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7758 The target being debugged may
7759 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7760 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7761 each supported by a command:
7762
7763 @itemize
7764 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7765 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7766 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7767 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7768
7769 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7770 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7771 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7772
7773 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7774 and then displayed at any time.
7775 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7776
7777 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7778 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7779 @end itemize
7780
7781 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7782 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7783 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7784 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7785 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7786 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7787 does the same thing.
7788
7789 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7790 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7791 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7792 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7793 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7794
7795 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7796 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7797 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7801 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7802 in the order they triggered.
7803 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7804 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7805 history records.
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7809 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7810 they have been triggered.
7811 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7812 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7813 and associates it with that identifier.
7814
7815 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7816 are not related except by this command.
7817 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7818 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7819 @end deffn
7820
7821
7822 @node JTAG Commands
7823 @chapter JTAG Commands
7824 @cindex JTAG Commands
7825 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7826 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7827 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7828 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7829 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7830
7831 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7832 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7833
7834 @itemize @bullet
7835 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7836 devices such as a CPUs.
7837 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7838 standard state machine (in parallel)
7839 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7840 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7841 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7842 while the reading previous ones.
7843 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7844 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7845 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7846 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7847 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7848 registers.
7849 @end itemize
7850
7851 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7852
7853 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7854 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7855 the order of TAP state transitions.
7856 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7857 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7858 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7859 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7860 these commands are not available.
7861
7862 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7863 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7864 that specify the entire register.
7865 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7866 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7867 The return value holds the original value of each
7868 of those fields.
7869
7870 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7871 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7872 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7873 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7874 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7875
7876 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7877 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7878
7879 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7880 in that state.
7881 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7882 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7883 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7884
7885 @quotation Warning
7886 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7887 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7888 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7889 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7890 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7891 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7892 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7893 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7894 @end quotation
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7898 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7899 This may be used for performance tuning.
7900
7901 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7902 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7903 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7904 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7905 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7906 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7907 @end deffn
7908
7909 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7910 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7911 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7912 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7913 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7914 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7915
7916 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7917 in that state.
7918 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7919 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7920 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7921
7922 @quotation Note
7923 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7924 register values, unlike data register values.
7925 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7926 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7927 @end quotation
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7931 Set values of reset signals.
7932 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7933 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7934 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7935 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7936 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7937 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7938 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7939
7940 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7941 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7942 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7943 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7944 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7945 instead of the TRST signal.
7946 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7947 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7948 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7949 with handlers for that event.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7953 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7954 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7955 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7956 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7957 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7958 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7959 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7960 The final state must also be stable.
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7964 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7965 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7966 Instructions often need some time
7967 to execute before they take effect.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7971 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7972
7973 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7974 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
7975 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
7976 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
7977 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7981 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
7982 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
7983 must also be enabled.
7984 Default is enabled.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @section TAP state names
7988 @cindex TAP state names
7989
7990 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
7991 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
7992 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
7993 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
7994
7995 @itemize @bullet
7996 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
7997 acts as if TRST were pulsed
7998 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
7999 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8000 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8001 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8002 through the data register
8003 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8004 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8005 for update or more shifting
8006 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8007 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8008 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8009 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8010 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8011 through the instruction register
8012 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8013 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8014 for update or more shifting
8015 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8016 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8017 @end itemize
8018
8019 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8020 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8021 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8022 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8023
8024 @itemize @bullet
8025 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8026 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8027 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8028 may not be as expected.
8029 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8030 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8031 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8032 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8033 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8034 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8035 @end itemize
8036
8037 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8038 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8039
8040 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8041 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8042 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8043 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8044
8045 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8046 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8047 @cindex SVF
8048
8049 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8050 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8051 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8052 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8053
8054 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8055 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8056 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8057 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8058 each command is logged before it is executed.
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8062 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8063 @cindex XSVF
8064
8065 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8066 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8067 Xilinx devices.
8068 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8069 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8070
8071 @quotation Important
8072 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8073 @end quotation
8074
8075 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8076 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8077 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8078 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8079 that TAP.
8080 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8081 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8082 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8083 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8087 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8088 after building the software.
8089 You may find them useful:
8090
8091 @itemize
8092 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8093 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8094 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8095 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8096 @end itemize
8097
8098 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8099 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8100 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8101 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8102 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8103 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8104 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8105
8106
8107 @node Utility Commands
8108 @chapter Utility Commands
8109 @cindex Utility Commands
8110
8111 @section RAM testing
8112 @cindex RAM testing
8113
8114 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8115 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8116 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8117 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8118 hardware problems.
8119
8120 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8121 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8122 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8123 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8124
8125 Load the memory testing functions with
8126
8127 @example
8128 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8129 @end example
8130
8131 to get access to the following facilities:
8132
8133 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8134 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8135 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8139 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8140 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8141 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8142 @end deffn
8143
8144 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8145 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8146 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8147 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8148 @end deffn
8149
8150 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8151 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8155 @cindex Firmware recovery
8156
8157 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8158 devices recovery with JTAG.
8159
8160 For quickstart instructions run:
8161 @example
8162 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8163 @end example
8164
8165 @node TFTP
8166 @chapter TFTP
8167 @cindex TFTP
8168 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8169 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8170
8171 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8172 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8173 server (tftpd). For example,
8174
8175 @example
8176 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8177 @end example
8178
8179 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8180 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8181
8182 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8183 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8184 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8185 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8186
8187 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8188 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8189 @cindex GDB
8190 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8191 to debug remote targets.
8192 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8193
8194 @itemize
8195 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8196 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8197 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8198 as shown in this chapter.
8199 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8200 that also will probably need to be configured.
8201 @end itemize
8202
8203 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8204 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8205 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8206 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8207 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8208 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8209
8210 @section Connecting to GDB
8211 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8212 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8213 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8214 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8215 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8216
8217 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8218
8219 @enumerate
8220 @item
8221 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8222 @example
8223 target remote localhost:3333
8224 @end example
8225 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8226
8227 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8228 @example
8229 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8230 @end example
8231 @item
8232 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8233 @example
8234 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8235 @end example
8236 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8237 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8238 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8239 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8240 @end enumerate
8241
8242 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8243 GDB command line.
8244
8245 @section Sample GDB session startup
8246
8247 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8248 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8249 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8250 small ARM program.
8251 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8252 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8253
8254 @example
8255 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8256 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8257 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8258 ...
8259 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8260 ...
8261 (gdb) load
8262 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8263 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8264 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8265 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8266 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8267 (gdb) continue
8268 Continuing.
8269 ...
8270 @end example
8271
8272 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8273 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8274 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8275 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8276
8277 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8278
8279 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8280 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8281 packet size and the device's memory map.
8282 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8283 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8284 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8285
8286 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8287 You may need to set those up by hand.
8288 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8289 something like:
8290
8291 @example
8292 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8293 @end example
8294
8295 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8296
8297 @example
8298 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8299 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8300 @end example
8301
8302 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8303 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8304 do not have such restrictions.
8305
8306 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8307 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8308 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8309
8310 @example
8311 define hook-step
8312 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8313 end
8314 define hookpost-step
8315 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8316 end
8317 @end example
8318
8319 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8320 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8321 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8322 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8323
8324 @section Programming using GDB
8325 @cindex Programming using GDB
8326 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8327
8328 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8329 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8330 @example
8331 gdb_memory_map disable
8332 @end example
8333 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8334 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8335 working area.
8336
8337 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8338 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8339 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8340 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8341
8342 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8343 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8344
8345 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8346 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8347 @example
8348 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8349 @end example
8350
8351 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8352 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8353
8354 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8355 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8356 will be used.
8357
8358 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8359 script can be executed:
8360 @example
8361 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8362 @end example
8363
8364 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8365 can be used.
8366 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8367 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8368 @cindex SMP
8369 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8370 @itemize @bullet
8371 @item j - smp status request
8372 @item J - smp set request
8373 @end itemize
8374
8375 OpenOCD implements :
8376 @itemize @bullet
8377 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8378 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8379 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8380 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8381 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8382 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8383 @end itemize
8384
8385 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8386 @itemize @bullet
8387 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8388 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8389 @example
8390 set $_core 1
8391 #Jc01 packet is sent
8392 print $_core
8393 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8394 @end example
8395
8396 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8397 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8398
8399 @example
8400 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8401 define toggle0
8402 maint packet Jc0
8403 continue
8404 main packet Jc-1
8405 end
8406 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8407 define toggle1
8408 maint packet Jc1
8409 continue
8410 main packet Jc-1
8411 end
8412 @end example
8413 @end itemize
8414
8415 @section RTOS Support
8416 @cindex RTOS Support
8417 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8418
8419 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8420 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8421
8422 @* An example setup is below:
8423
8424 @example
8425 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8426 @end example
8427
8428 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8429
8430 Currently supported rtos's include:
8431 @itemize @bullet
8432 @item @option{eCos}
8433 @item @option{ThreadX}
8434 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8435 @item @option{linux}
8436 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8437 @item @option{embKernel}
8438 @item @option{mqx}
8439 @end itemize
8440
8441 @quotation Note
8442 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8443 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8444 @end quotation
8445
8446 @table @code
8447 @item eCos symbols
8448 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8449 @item ThreadX symbols
8450 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8451 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8452 @raggedright
8453 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8454 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8455 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8456 @end raggedright
8457 @item linux symbols
8458 init_task.
8459 @item ChibiOS symbols
8460 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8461 @item embKernel symbols
8462 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8463 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8464 @item mqx symbols
8465 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8466 @end table
8467
8468 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8469 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8470
8471 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8472 along with the project:
8473
8474 @table @code
8475 @item FreeRTOS
8476 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8477 @end table
8478
8479 @node Tcl Scripting API
8480 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8481 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8482 @cindex Tcl scripts
8483 @section API rules
8484
8485 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8486 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8487 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8488
8489 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8490 pair list and lists.
8491
8492 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8493 list.
8494
8495 @example
8496 > set foo(me) Duane
8497 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8498 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8499 > set foo(duck) Donald
8500 @end example
8501
8502 If one does this:
8503
8504 @example
8505 > set foo
8506 @end example
8507
8508 The result is:
8509
8510 @example
8511 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8512 @end example
8513
8514 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8515
8516 @verbatim
8517 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8518 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8519 }
8520 @end verbatim
8521
8522 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8523 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8524
8525 @section Internal low-level Commands
8526
8527 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8528 invoke directly.
8529
8530 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8531 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8532 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8533
8534 @itemize @bullet
8535 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8536
8537 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8538 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8539
8540 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8541 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8542
8543 Return information about the flash banks
8544
8545 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8546
8547 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8548 its execution. Example:
8549
8550 @example
8551 > capture "reset init"
8552 @end example
8553
8554 @end itemize
8555
8556 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8557 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8558 called "flash_banks".
8559
8560 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8561
8562 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8563 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8564 holds one of the following values:
8565
8566 @itemize @bullet
8567 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8568 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8569 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8570 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8571 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8572 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8573 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8574 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8575 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8576 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8577 @end itemize
8578
8579 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8580
8581 @quotation Note
8582 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8583 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8584 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8585 is jim, not real tcl).
8586 @end quotation
8587
8588 @section Tcl RPC server
8589 @cindex RPC
8590
8591 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8592 commands and receive the results.
8593
8594 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8595 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8596 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8597 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8598 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8599
8600 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8601 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8602 @command{capture} command.
8603
8604 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8605
8606 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8607 @cindex RPC Notifications
8608
8609 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8610 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8611
8612 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8613 in the following format.
8614
8615 @verbatim
8616 type target_event event [event-name]
8617 type target_state state [state-name]
8618 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8619 @end verbatim
8620
8621 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8622 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8623 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8624 Defaults to off.
8625
8626 @end deffn
8627
8628 @node FAQ
8629 @chapter FAQ
8630 @cindex faq
8631 @enumerate
8632 @anchor{faqrtck}
8633 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8634 @cindex RTCK
8635 @cindex adaptive clocking
8636 @*
8637
8638 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8639 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8640 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8641 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8642
8643 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8644 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8645 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8646 @enumerate
8647 @item
8648 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8649 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8650 @item
8651 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8652 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8653 @end enumerate
8654
8655 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8656 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8657 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8658 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8659 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8660 power).
8661
8662 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8663 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8664 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8665 ARM926 scenario).
8666 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8667 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8668 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8669
8670 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8671 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8672 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8673 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8674
8675 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8676
8677 In order to make use of this,
8678 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8679 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8680
8681 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8682 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8683 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8684 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8685 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8686
8687 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8688 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8689 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8690 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8691
8692 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8693 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8694 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8695 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8696 with a CPLD.
8697 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8698 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8699 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8700 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8701 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8702 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8703
8704 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8705
8706 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8707
8708 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8709 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8710 depending on the chips on your board.
8711 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8712 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8713 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8714
8715 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8716 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8717 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8718
8719 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8720 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8721 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8722 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8723
8724 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8725 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8726 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8727 this way.
8728
8729 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8730 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8731 clock rate.
8732 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8733 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8734 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8735
8736 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8737
8738 @example
8739 # Example: 1.234MHz
8740 adapter_khz 1234
8741 @end example
8742
8743
8744 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8745
8746 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8747 around Windows filenames.
8748
8749 @example
8750 > echo \a
8751
8752 > echo @{\a@}
8753 \a
8754 > echo "\a"
8755
8756 >
8757 @end example
8758
8759
8760 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8761
8762 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8763 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8764 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8765
8766 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8767 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8768 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8769
8770 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8771 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8772 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8773
8774 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8775
8776 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8777 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8778 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8779 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8780
8781 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8782 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8783 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8784
8785 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8786 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8787
8788 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8789 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8790 memory read caused data abort".
8791
8792 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8793 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8794 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8795 be done, feel free to add this here.
8796
8797 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8798 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8799 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8800 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8801 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8802 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8803 gracefully stops.
8804
8805 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8806 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8807 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8808
8809 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8810 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8811 bytes. Painful...
8812
8813
8814 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8815 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8816
8817 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8818 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8819 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8820 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8821 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8822 reset, everything else should work fine.
8823
8824 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8825 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8826 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8827 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8828
8829 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8830 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8831 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8832 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8833
8834 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8835
8836 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8837 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8838 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8839 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8840
8841 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8842 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8843 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8844 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8845
8846 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8847 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8848 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8849
8850 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8851 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8852
8853 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8854 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8855 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8856 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8857 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8858 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8859 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8860 clock frequency?
8861
8862 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8863 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8864 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8865 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8866 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8867
8868 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8869
8870 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8871 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8872 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8873 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8874 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8875 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8876 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8877
8878 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8879
8880 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8881 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8882 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8883 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8884
8885 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8886 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8887 particular order?
8888
8889 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8890 the same order used by the hardware.
8891
8892 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8893 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8894 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8895 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8896 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8897 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8898
8899 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8900 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8901 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8902 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8903
8904 @itemize @bullet
8905 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8906 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8907 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8908 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8909 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8910 @end itemize
8911
8912 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8913
8914 @itemize @bullet
8915 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8916 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8917 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8918 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8919 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8920 @end itemize
8921
8922
8923 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8924 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8925 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8926
8927 TODO.
8928
8929 @end enumerate
8930
8931 @node Tcl Crash Course
8932 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8933 @cindex Tcl
8934
8935 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8936 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8937 how the Tcl scripts work.
8938
8939 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8940 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8941 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8942 OpenOCD.
8943
8944 @section Tcl Rule #1
8945 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8946 @enumerate
8947 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8948 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8949 @end enumerate
8950
8951 The Tcl equal is this:
8952
8953 @enumerate
8954 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8955 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8956 @end enumerate
8957
8958 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8959 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8960
8961 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8962 There is a second pair of rules.
8963 @enumerate
8964 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8965 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8966 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8967 in Tcl.
8968 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8969 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8970 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8971 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8972 @end enumerate
8973
8974 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8975 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8976 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8977 Everything is a string}
8978
8979 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8980 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8981 difference is subtle.
8982 @enumerate
8983 @item Parse Time
8984 @item Evaluation Time
8985 @end enumerate
8986
8987 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8988 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8989 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8990
8991 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
8992 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
8993 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
8994 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
8995
8996 @itemize @bullet
8997 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
8998 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
8999 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9000 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9001 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9002 @example
9003 # bash example
9004 X=`date`
9005 echo "The Date is: $X"
9006 # Tcl example
9007 set X [date]
9008 puts "The Date is: $X"
9009 @end example
9010 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9011 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9012 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9013 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9014 is a string}
9015 @example
9016 set x "Dinner"
9017 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9018 @end example
9019 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9020 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9021 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9022 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9023 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9024 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9025 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9026 @end itemize
9027
9028 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9029
9030 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9031
9032 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9033
9034 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9035 the normal way.
9036
9037 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9038 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9039 line is immedatly executed.
9040
9041 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9042 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9043
9044 @subsection Command Execution
9045
9046 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9047 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9048 control flow operators.
9049
9050 Commands are executed like this:
9051
9052 @enumerate
9053 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9054 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9055 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9056 @end enumerate
9057
9058 It sort of works like this:
9059 @example
9060 for(;;)@{
9061 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9062
9063 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9064
9065 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9066 @}
9067 @end example
9068
9069 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9070 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9071 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9072 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9073 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9074 ``LookupCommand()''
9075
9076 @subsection The FOR command
9077
9078 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9079 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9080 command just like any other command.
9081
9082 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9083 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9084 are:
9085
9086 @enumerate 0
9087 @item The ascii text 'for'
9088 @item The start text
9089 @item The test expression
9090 @item The next text
9091 @item The body text
9092 @end enumerate
9093
9094 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9095 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9096 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9097 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9098
9099 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9100 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9101
9102 @example
9103 int
9104 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9105 int *argc,
9106 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9107 @end example
9108
9109 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9110 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9111 still operates in the same basic way.
9112
9113 @subsection FOR command implementation
9114
9115 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9116 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9117
9118 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9119
9120 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9121
9122 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9123 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9124 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9125
9126 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9127 expression and returns a value.
9128
9129 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9130 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9131 @example
9132 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9133
9134 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9135
9136 int
9137 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9138 int argc,
9139 char **argv )
9140 @{
9141 if( argc != 5 )@{
9142 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9143 return ERROR;
9144 @}
9145
9146 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9147
9148 // Execute the start statement.
9149 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9150
9151 // Top of loop test
9152 for(;;)@{
9153 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9154 if( i == 0 )
9155 break;
9156
9157 // Execute the body
9158 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9159
9160 // Execute the LOOP part
9161 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9162 @}
9163
9164 // Return no error
9165 SetResult( interp, "" );
9166 return SUCCESS;
9167 @}
9168 @end example
9169
9170 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9171 in the same basic way.
9172
9173 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9174
9175 @subsection source and find commands
9176 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9177 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9178 @*Remember the parsing rules
9179 @enumerate
9180 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9181 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9182 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9183 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9184 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9185 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9186 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9187 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9188 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9189 @end enumerate
9190 @subsection format command
9191 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9192 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9193 @b{sprintf()}.
9194 @b{Example}
9195 @example
9196 set x 6
9197 set y 7
9198 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9199 @end example
9200 @enumerate
9201 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9202 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9203 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9204 @* Refer to Rule #1
9205 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9206 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9207 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9208 @end enumerate
9209 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9210 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9211 @example
9212 #1 Good
9213 proc someproc @{@} @{
9214 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9215 @}
9216 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9217 #2 Good - no variables
9218 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9219 #3 Good Curly Braces
9220 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9221 puts "Time: [date]"
9222 @}
9223 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9224 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9225 @end example
9226 @enumerate
9227 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9228 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9229 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9230 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9231 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9232 command.
9233 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9234 @*There are 4 examples:
9235 @enumerate
9236 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9237 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9238 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9239 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9240 @end enumerate
9241
9242 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9243 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9244 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9245
9246 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9247 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9248 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9249 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9250 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9251 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9252 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9253 @end enumerate
9254 @subsection Global Variables
9255 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9256 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9257 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9258 @example
9259 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9260 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9261 global x #Global variable X
9262 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9263 @}
9264 @end example
9265 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9266 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9267 @example
9268 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9269 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9270 # Create var name
9271 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9272 # Make it a global
9273 global $vn
9274 # Set it.
9275 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9276 @}
9277 @end example
9278 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9279 @example
9280 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9281 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9282 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9283 @}
9284 @end example
9285
9286 @include fdl.texi
9287
9288 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9289 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9290 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9291 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9292 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9293 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9294
9295 @printindex cp
9296
9297 @node Command and Driver Index
9298 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9299 @printindex fn
9300
9301 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)